1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217 */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
224 };
225
226 /**
227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228 *
229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231 *
232 * @def: the channel definition
233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242 */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246
247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248
249 bool radar_enabled;
250
251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253
254 /**
255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266 * for changes/removal.)
267 */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272
273 /**
274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275 *
276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279 * done.
280 *
281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285 */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292
293 /**
294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295 *
296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298 *
299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300 * also implies a change in the AID.
301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324 * changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329 * context had been assigned.
330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333 * keep alive) changed.
334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342 * status changed.
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344 */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32),
379
380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382
383 /*
384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386 * filtering will be disabled.
387 */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389
390 /**
391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397 * once each time the timeout triggers.
398 */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 RSSI_EVENT,
401 MLME_EVENT,
402 BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405
406 /**
407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410 */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415
416 /**
417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419 */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423
424 /**
425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430 */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 AUTH_EVENT,
433 ASSOC_EVENT,
434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437
438 /**
439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443 */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 MLME_SUCCESS,
446 MLME_DENIED,
447 MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455 */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 u16 reason;
460 };
461
462 /**
463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465 * @tid: the tid
466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467 */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 u16 tid;
471 u16 ssn;
472 };
473
474 /**
475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480 * @u:union holding the fields above
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 union {
485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 } u;
489 };
490
491 /**
492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493 *
494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495 *
496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498 */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503
504 /**
505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506 *
507 * @lci: LCI subelement content
508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509 * @lci_len: LCI data length
510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511 */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 const u8 *lci;
514 const u8 *civicloc;
515 size_t lci_len;
516 size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518
519 /**
520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522 *
523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525 */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 u32 min_interval;
528 u32 max_interval;
529 };
530
531 /**
532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533 *
534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536 *
537 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538 * @addr: (link) address used locally
539 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543 * ACK, BACK or both
544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579 * the current band.
580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619 * station.
620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621 * responder functionality.
622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632 * connected to (STA)
633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637 * interval.
638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
647 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
648 * for read access.
649 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
657 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
658 * for read access.
659 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
660 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
661 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
662 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
663 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664 * beamformer
665 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
666 * beamformee
667 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668 * beamformer
669 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
670 * beamformee
671 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672 * beamformer
673 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
674 * beamformee
675 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
676 * beamformer
677 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
678 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
679 * bandwidth
680 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681 * beamformer
682 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
683 * beamformee
684 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
685 * beamformer
686 */
687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
688 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
689
690 const u8 *bssid;
691 unsigned int link_id;
692 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
693 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
694 bool uora_exists;
695 u8 uora_ocw_range;
696 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
697 bool he_support;
698 bool twt_requester;
699 bool twt_responder;
700 bool twt_protected;
701 bool twt_broadcast;
702 /* erp related data */
703 bool use_cts_prot;
704 bool use_short_preamble;
705 bool use_short_slot;
706 bool enable_beacon;
707 u8 dtim_period;
708 u16 beacon_int;
709 u16 assoc_capability;
710 u64 sync_tsf;
711 u32 sync_device_ts;
712 u8 sync_dtim_count;
713 u32 basic_rates;
714 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
715 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
716 u16 ht_operation_mode;
717 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
718 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
719 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
720 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
721 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
722 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
723 bool qos;
724 bool hidden_ssid;
725 int txpower;
726 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
727 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
728 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
729 u16 max_idle_period;
730 bool protected_keep_alive;
731 bool ftm_responder;
732 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
733 /* Multiple BSSID data */
734 bool nontransmitted;
735 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
736 u8 bssid_index;
737 u8 bssid_indicator;
738 bool ema_ap;
739 u8 profile_periodicity;
740 struct {
741 u32 params;
742 u16 nss_set;
743 } he_oper;
744 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
745 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
746 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
747 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
748 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
749 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
750 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
751 u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
752 u8 pwr_reduction;
753 bool eht_support;
754 u16 eht_puncturing;
755
756 bool csa_active;
757 u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
758
759 bool mu_mimo_owner;
760 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
761
762 bool color_change_active;
763 u8 color_change_color;
764
765 bool ht_ldpc;
766 bool vht_ldpc;
767 bool he_ldpc;
768 bool vht_su_beamformer;
769 bool vht_su_beamformee;
770 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
771 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
772 bool he_su_beamformer;
773 bool he_su_beamformee;
774 bool he_mu_beamformer;
775 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
776 bool eht_su_beamformer;
777 bool eht_su_beamformee;
778 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
779 };
780
781 /**
782 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
783 *
784 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
785 *
786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
787 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
788 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
789 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
790 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
791 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
792 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
793 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
794 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
795 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
796 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
797 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
800 * station
801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
802 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
803 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
804 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
805 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
806 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
807 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
808 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
809 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
810 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
811 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
812 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
813 * hardware queue.
814 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
815 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
816 * is for the whole aggregation.
817 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
818 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
819 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
820 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
821 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
822 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
823 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
824 * off-channel operation.
825 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
826 * (header conversion)
827 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
828 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
829 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
830 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
831 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
832 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
833 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
834 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
835 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
836 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
837 * queue gets full.
838 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
839 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
840 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
841 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
842 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
843 * should kick the MLME state machine.
844 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
845 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
846 * status to user space)
847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
849 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
851 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
852 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
853 * handled properly by the device.
854 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
855 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
856 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
857 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
858 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
859 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
861 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
862 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
863 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
864 * PS-Poll responses.
865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
866 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
867 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
868 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
869 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
870 * monitor injection).
871 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
872 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
873 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
874 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
875 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
876 *
877 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
878 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
879 */
880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
888 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
889 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
890 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
891 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
892 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
893 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
894 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
895 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
896 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
897 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
898 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
899 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
900 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
901 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
902 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
904 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
906 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
907 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
908 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
909 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
910 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
911 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
912 };
913
914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
915
916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
917
918 /**
919 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
920 *
921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
922 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
924 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
925 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
927 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
930 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
931 * it can be sent out.
932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
933 * has already been assigned to this frame.
934 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
935 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
936 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
937 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
938 * for sequence number assignment
939 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
940 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
941 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
942 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
943 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
944 * it's intended for an MLD.
945 *
946 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
947 */
948 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
949 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
950 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
951 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
953 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
955 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
956 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
957 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
958 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
959 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
960 };
961
962 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
963 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
964 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
965 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
966
967 /**
968 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
969 *
970 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
971 *
972 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
973 */
974 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
975 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
976 };
977
978 /*
979 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
980 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
981 */
982 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
984 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
985 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
986 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
988 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
989 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
990
991 /**
992 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
993 * Rate Control algorithm.
994 *
995 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
996 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
997 *
998 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
999 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1000 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1004 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1006 * Greenfield mode.
1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1008 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1009 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1010 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1012 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1013 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1014 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1015 */
1016 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1017 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1018 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1019 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1020
1021 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1023 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1024 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1025 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1026 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1027 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1028 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1029 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1030 };
1031
1032
1033 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1034 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1035
1036 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1037 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1038
1039 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1041
1042 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1043 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1044
1045 /**
1046 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1047 *
1048 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1049 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1050 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1051 *
1052 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1053 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1054 *
1055 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1056 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1057 *
1058 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1059 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1060 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1061 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1062 * information::
1063 *
1064 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1065 *
1066 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1067 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1068 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1069 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1070 * information should then contain::
1071 *
1072 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1073 *
1074 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1075 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1076 */
1077 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1078 s8 idx;
1079 u16 count:5,
1080 flags:11;
1081 } __packed;
1082
1083 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1084
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1085 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1086 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1087 {
1088 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1089 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1090 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1091 }
1092
1093 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1094 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1095 {
1096 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1097 }
1098
1099 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1100 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1101 {
1102 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1103 }
1104
1105 /**
1106 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1107 *
1108 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1109 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1110 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1111 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1112 *
1113 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1114 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1115 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1116 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1117 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1118 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1119 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1120 * @control: union part for control data
1121 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1122 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1123 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1124 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1125 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1126 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1127 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1128 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1129 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1130 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1131 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1132 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1133 * @pad: padding
1134 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1135 * @status: union part for status data
1136 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1137 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1138 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1139 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1140 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1141 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1142 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1143 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1144 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1145 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1146 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1147 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1148 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1149 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1150 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1151 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1152 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1153 */
1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1155 /* common information */
1156 u32 flags;
1157 u32 band:3,
1158 ack_frame_id:13,
1159 hw_queue:4,
1160 tx_time_est:10;
1161 /* 2 free bits */
1162
1163 union {
1164 struct {
1165 union {
1166 /* rate control */
1167 struct {
1168 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1169 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1170 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1171 u8 use_rts:1;
1172 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1173 u8 short_preamble:1;
1174 u8 skip_table:1;
1175 /* 2 bytes free */
1176 };
1177 /* only needed before rate control */
1178 unsigned long jiffies;
1179 };
1180 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1181 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1182 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1183 u32 flags;
1184 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1185 } control;
1186 struct {
1187 u64 cookie;
1188 } ack;
1189 struct {
1190 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1191 s32 ack_signal;
1192 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1193 u8 ampdu_len;
1194 u8 antenna;
1195 u8 pad;
1196 u16 tx_time;
1197 u8 flags;
1198 u8 pad2;
1199 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1200 } status;
1201 struct {
1202 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1203 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1204 u8 pad[4];
1205
1206 void *rate_driver_data[
1207 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1208 };
1209 void *driver_data[
1210 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1211 };
1212 };
1213
1214 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1215 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1216 {
1217 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1218 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1219 */
1220 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1221 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1222 }
1223
1224 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1225 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1226 {
1227 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1228 }
1229
1230 /***
1231 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1232 *
1233 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1234 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1235 *
1236 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1237 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1238 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1239 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1240 * that was used when sending the packet.
1241 */
1242 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1243 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1244 u8 try_count;
1245 u8 tx_power_idx;
1246 };
1247
1248 /**
1249 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1250 *
1251 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1252 * @info: Basic tx status information
1253 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1254 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1255 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1256 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1257 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1258 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1259 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1260 */
1261 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1262 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1263 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1264 struct sk_buff *skb;
1265 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1266 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1267 u8 n_rates;
1268
1269 struct list_head *free_list;
1270 };
1271
1272 /**
1273 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1274 *
1275 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1276 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1277 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1278 *
1279 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1280 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1281 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1282 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1283 */
1284 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1285 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1286 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1287 const u8 *common_ies;
1288 size_t common_ie_len;
1289 };
1290
1291
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1292 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1293 {
1294 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1295 }
1296
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1297 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1298 {
1299 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1300 }
1301
1302 /**
1303 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1304 *
1305 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1306 *
1307 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1308 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1309 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1310 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1311 *
1312 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1313 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1314 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1315 */
1316 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1317 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1318 {
1319 int i;
1320
1321 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1322 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1323 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1324 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1325 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1326 /* clear the rate counts */
1327 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1328 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1329 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1330 }
1331
1332
1333 /**
1334 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1335 *
1336 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1337 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1338 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1339 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1340 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1341 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1342 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1343 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1344 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1345 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1346 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1347 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1348 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1349 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1350 * de-duplication by itself.
1351 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1352 * the frame.
1353 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1354 * the frame.
1355 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1356 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1357 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1358 * merging.
1359 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1360 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1361 * (including FCS) was received.
1362 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1363 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1364 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1365 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1366 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1367 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1368 * each A-MPDU
1369 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1370 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1371 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1372 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1373 * on this subframe
1374 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1375 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1376 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1377 * done by the hardware
1378 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1379 * processing it in any regular way.
1380 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1381 * them for sniffing purposes.
1382 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1383 * monitor interfaces.
1384 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1385 * them for sniffing purposes.
1386 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1387 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1388 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1389 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1390 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1391 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1392 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1393 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1394 * interleaved with other frames.
1395 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1396 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1397 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1398 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1399 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1400 * in the skb.
1401 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1402 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1403 * the first subframe.
1404 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1405 * be done in the hardware.
1406 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1407 * frame
1408 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1409 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1410 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1411 *
1412 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1413 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1414 * - DATA3_CODING
1415 * - DATA5_GI
1416 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1417 * - DATA6_NSTS
1418 * - DATA3_STBC
1419 *
1420 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1421 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1422 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1423 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1424 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1425 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1426 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1427 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1428 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1429 * hardware or driver)
1430 */
1431 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1432 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1433 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1434 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2),
1435 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1436 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1437 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1438 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1439 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7),
1440 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1441 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1442 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1443 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1444 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1445 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1446 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1447 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1448 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16),
1449 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17),
1450 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1451 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1452 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1453 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1454 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1455 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1456 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1457 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1458 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1459 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1460 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1461 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1462 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1463 };
1464
1465 /**
1466 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1467 *
1468 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1469 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1470 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1471 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1472 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1473 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1474 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1475 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1476 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1477 */
1478 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1479 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1480 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1481 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1482 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1483 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1484 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1485 };
1486
1487 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1488
1489 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1490 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1491 RX_ENC_HT,
1492 RX_ENC_VHT,
1493 RX_ENC_HE,
1494 RX_ENC_EHT,
1495 };
1496
1497 /**
1498 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1499 *
1500 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1501 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1502 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1503 *
1504 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1505 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1506 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1507 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1508 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1509 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1510 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1511 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1512 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1513 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1514 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1515 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1516 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1517 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1518 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1519 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1520 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1521 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1522 * values were filled.
1523 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1524 * support dB or unspecified units)
1525 * @antenna: antenna used
1526 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1527 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1528 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1529 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1530 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1531 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1532 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1533 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1534 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1535 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1536 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1537 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1538 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1539 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1540 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1541 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1542 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1543 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1544 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1545 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1546 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1547 * @link_valid.
1548 */
1549 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1550 u64 mactime;
1551 union {
1552 u64 boottime_ns;
1553 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1554 };
1555 u32 device_timestamp;
1556 u32 ampdu_reference;
1557 u32 flag;
1558 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1559 u8 enc_flags;
1560 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1561 union {
1562 struct {
1563 u8 he_ru:3;
1564 u8 he_gi:2;
1565 u8 he_dcm:1;
1566 };
1567 struct {
1568 u8 ru:4;
1569 u8 gi:2;
1570 } eht;
1571 };
1572 u8 rate_idx;
1573 u8 nss;
1574 u8 rx_flags;
1575 u8 band;
1576 u8 antenna;
1577 s8 signal;
1578 u8 chains;
1579 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1580 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1581 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1582 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1583 };
1584
1585 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1586 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1587 {
1588 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1589 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1590 }
1591
1592 /**
1593 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1594 *
1595 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1596 *
1597 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1598 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1599 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1600 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1601 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1602 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1603 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1604 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1605 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1606 * for more.
1607 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1608 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1609 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1610 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1611 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1612 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1613 * operating channel.
1614 */
1615 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1616 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1617 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1618 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1619 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1620 };
1621
1622
1623 /**
1624 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1625 *
1626 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1627 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1628 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1629 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1630 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1631 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1632 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1633 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1634 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1635 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1636 */
1637 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1638 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1639 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1640 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1641 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1642 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1643 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1644 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1645 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1646 };
1647
1648 /**
1649 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1650 *
1651 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1652 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1653 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1654 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1655 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1656 */
1657 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1658 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1659 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1660 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1661 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1662
1663 /* keep last */
1664 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1665 };
1666
1667 /**
1668 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1669 *
1670 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1671 *
1672 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1673 *
1674 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1675 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1676 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1677 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1678 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1679 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1680 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1681 *
1682 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1683 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1684 *
1685 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1686 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1687 *
1688 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1689 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1690 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1691 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1692 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1693 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1694 *
1695 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1696 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1697 * configured for an HT channel.
1698 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1699 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1700 */
1701 struct ieee80211_conf {
1702 u32 flags;
1703 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1704
1705 u16 listen_interval;
1706 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1707
1708 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1709
1710 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1711 bool radar_enabled;
1712 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1713 };
1714
1715 /**
1716 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1717 *
1718 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1719 * operation.
1720 *
1721 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1722 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1723 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1724 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1725 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1726 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1727 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1728 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1729 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1730 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1731 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1732 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1733 * channel, expressed in TU.
1734 */
1735 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1736 u64 timestamp;
1737 u32 device_timestamp;
1738 bool block_tx;
1739 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1740 u8 count;
1741 u32 delay;
1742 };
1743
1744 /**
1745 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1746 *
1747 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1748 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1749 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1750 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1751 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1752 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1753 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1754 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1755 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1756 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1757 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1758 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1759 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1760 * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of
1761 * SMPS mode via debugfs.
1762 */
1763 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1764 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1765 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1766 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1767 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1768 IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE = BIT(4),
1769 };
1770
1771
1772 /**
1773 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1774 *
1775 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1776 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1777 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1778 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1779 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1780 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1781 * mac80211.
1782 */
1783
1784 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1785 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1786 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1787 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1788 };
1789
1790 /**
1791 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1792 * @assoc: association status
1793 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1794 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1795 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1796 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1797 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1798 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1799 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1800 * P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1801 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1802 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1803 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1804 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1805 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1806 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1807 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1808 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1809 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1810 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1811 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1812 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1813 * your driver/device needs to do.
1814 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1815 * (station mode only)
1816 */
1817 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1818 /* association related data */
1819 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1820 bool ibss_creator;
1821 bool ps;
1822 u16 aid;
1823 u16 eml_cap;
1824 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1825
1826 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1827 int arp_addr_cnt;
1828 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1829 size_t ssid_len;
1830 bool s1g;
1831 bool idle;
1832 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1833 };
1834
1835 /**
1836 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1837 *
1838 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1839 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1840 *
1841 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1842 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1843 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1844 * or the BSS we're associated to
1845 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1846 * indexed by link ID
1847 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1848 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1849 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1850 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1851 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1852 * Must be a subset of valid_links.
1853 * @addr: address of this interface
1854 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1855 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1856 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1857 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1858 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1859 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1860 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1861 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1862 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1863 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1864 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1865 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1866 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1867 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1868 * restrictions.
1869 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1870 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1871 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1872 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1873 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1874 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1875 * interface.
1876 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1877 * for this interface.
1878 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1879 * sizeof(void \*).
1880 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1881 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1882 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1883 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1884 */
1885 struct ieee80211_vif {
1886 enum nl80211_iftype type;
1887 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1888 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1889 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1890 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1891 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1892 bool p2p;
1893
1894 u8 cab_queue;
1895 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1896
1897 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1898
1899 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1900 u32 driver_flags;
1901 u32 offload_flags;
1902
1903 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1904 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1905 #endif
1906
1907 bool probe_req_reg;
1908 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1909
1910 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1911
1912 /* must be last */
1913 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1914 };
1915
1916 /**
1917 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1918 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1919 * Return: the usable link bitmap
1920 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1921 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1922 {
1923 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1924 }
1925
1926 /**
1927 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1928 * @vif: the vif
1929 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1930 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1931 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1932 {
1933 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1934 return vif->valid_links != 0;
1935 }
1936
1937 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
1938 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
1939 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
1940 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
1941 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1942
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1943 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1944 {
1945 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1946 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1947 #endif
1948 return false;
1949 }
1950
1951 /**
1952 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1953 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1954 *
1955 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1956 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1957 *
1958 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1959 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1960 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1961 */
1962 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1963
1964 /**
1965 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1966 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1967 *
1968 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1969 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1970 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1971 */
1972 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1973
1974 /**
1975 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1976 * @vif: the interface to check
1977 */
lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1978 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1979 {
1980 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1981 }
1982
1983 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
1984 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
1985 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1986
1987 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
1988 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
1989 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1990
1991 /**
1992 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1993 *
1994 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1995 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1996 *
1997 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1998 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1999 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2000 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2002 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2003 * generation in software.
2004 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2005 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2006 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2007 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2008 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2009 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2010 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2011 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2012 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2013 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2014 * MIC.
2015 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2016 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2017 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2018 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2019 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2020 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2021 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2022 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2023 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2024 * only for management frames (MFP).
2025 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2026 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2027 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2028 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2029 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2030 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2031 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2032 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2033 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2034 * generation only
2035 */
2036 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2037 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2038 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2039 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2040 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2041 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2042 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2043 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2044 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2045 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2046 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2047 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2048 };
2049
2050 /**
2051 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2052 *
2053 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2054 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2055 *
2056 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2057 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2058 * encrypted in hardware.
2059 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2060 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2061 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2062 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2063 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2064 * @keylen: key material length
2065 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2066 * data block:
2067 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2068 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2069 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2070 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2071 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2072 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2073 */
2074 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2075 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2076 u32 cipher;
2077 u8 icv_len;
2078 u8 iv_len;
2079 u8 hw_key_idx;
2080 s8 keyidx;
2081 u16 flags;
2082 s8 link_id;
2083 u8 keylen;
2084 u8 key[];
2085 };
2086
2087 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2088
2089 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2090 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2091
2092 /**
2093 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2094 *
2095 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2096 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2097 * reverse order than in packet)
2098 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2099 * reverse order than in packet)
2100 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2101 * reverse order than in packet)
2102 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2103 * reverse order than in packet)
2104 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2105 */
2106 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2107 union {
2108 struct {
2109 u32 iv32;
2110 u16 iv16;
2111 } tkip;
2112 struct {
2113 u8 pn[6];
2114 } ccmp;
2115 struct {
2116 u8 pn[6];
2117 } aes_cmac;
2118 struct {
2119 u8 pn[6];
2120 } aes_gmac;
2121 struct {
2122 u8 pn[6];
2123 } gcmp;
2124 struct {
2125 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2126 u8 seq_len;
2127 } hw;
2128 };
2129 };
2130
2131 /**
2132 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2133 *
2134 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2135 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2136 *
2137 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2138 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2139 */
2140 enum set_key_cmd {
2141 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2142 };
2143
2144 /**
2145 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2146 *
2147 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2148 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2149 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2150 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2151 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2152 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2153 */
2154 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2155 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2156 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2157 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2158 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2159 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2160 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2161 };
2162
2163 /**
2164 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2165 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2166 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2167 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2168 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2169 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2170 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2171 *
2172 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2173 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2174 */
2175 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2176 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2177 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2178 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2179 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2180 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2181 };
2182
2183 /**
2184 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2185 *
2186 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2187 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2188 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2189 */
2190 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2191 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2192 struct {
2193 s8 idx;
2194 u8 count;
2195 u8 count_cts;
2196 u8 count_rts;
2197 u16 flags;
2198 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2199 };
2200
2201 /**
2202 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2203 *
2204 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2205 *
2206 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2207 * to the STA.
2208 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2209 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2210 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2211 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2212 * per peer TPC.
2213 */
2214 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2215 s16 power;
2216 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2217 };
2218
2219 /**
2220 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2221 *
2222 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2223 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2224 *
2225 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2226 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2227 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2228 *
2229 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2230 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2231 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2232 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2233 *
2234 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2235 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2236 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2237 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2238 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2239 */
2240 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2241 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2242
2243 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2244 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2245 };
2246
2247 /**
2248 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2249 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2250 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2251 *
2252 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2253 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2254 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2255 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2256 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2257 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2258 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2259 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2260 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2261 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2262 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2263 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2264 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2265 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2266 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2267 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2268 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2269 * the station moves to associated state.
2270 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2271 *
2272 */
2273 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2274 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2275
2276 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2277 u8 link_id;
2278 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2279
2280 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2281 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2282 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2283 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2284 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2285 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2286
2287 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2288
2289 u8 rx_nss;
2290 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2291 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2292 };
2293
2294 /**
2295 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2296 *
2297 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2298 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2299 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2300 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2301 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2302 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2303 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2304 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2305 *
2306 * @addr: MAC address
2307 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2308 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2309 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2310 * Can be modified by driver.
2311 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2312 * otherwise always false)
2313 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2314 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2315 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2316 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2317 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2318 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2319 * @rates: rate control selection table
2320 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2321 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2322 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2323 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2324 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2325 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2326 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2327 * unlimited.
2328 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2329 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2330 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2331 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2332 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2333 * is used for non-data frames
2334 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2335 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2336 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2337 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2338 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2339 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2340 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2341 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2342 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2343 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2344 * by the AP.
2345 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2346 */
2347 struct ieee80211_sta {
2348 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2349 u16 aid;
2350 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2351 bool wme;
2352 u8 uapsd_queues;
2353 u8 max_sp;
2354 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2355 bool tdls;
2356 bool tdls_initiator;
2357 bool mfp;
2358 bool mlo;
2359 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2360
2361 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2362
2363 bool support_p2p_ps;
2364
2365 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2366
2367 u16 valid_links;
2368 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2369 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2370
2371 /* must be last */
2372 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2373 };
2374
2375 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2376 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2377 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2378 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2379 {
2380 return true;
2381 }
2382 #endif
2383
2384 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2385 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2386 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2387
2388 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2389 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2390 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2391
2392 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2393 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2394 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2395 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2396 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2397
2398 /**
2399 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2400 *
2401 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2402 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2403 *
2404 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2405 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2406 */
2407 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2408 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2409 };
2410
2411 /**
2412 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2413 *
2414 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2415 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2416 */
2417 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2418 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2419 };
2420
2421 /**
2422 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2423 *
2424 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2425 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2426 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2427 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2428 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2429 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2430 *
2431 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2432 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2433 */
2434 struct ieee80211_txq {
2435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2436 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2437 u8 tid;
2438 u8 ac;
2439
2440 /* must be last */
2441 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2442 };
2443
2444 /**
2445 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2446 *
2447 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2448 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2449 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2450 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2451 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2452 *
2453 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2454 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2455 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2456 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2457 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2458 * algorithm.
2459 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2460 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2461 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2462 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2463 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2464 * CCK frames.
2465 *
2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2467 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2468 * the FCS at the end.
2469 *
2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2471 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2472 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2473 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2474 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2475 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2476 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2477 *
2478 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2479 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2480 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2481 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2482 *
2483 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2484 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2485 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2486 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2487 *
2488 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2489 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2490 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2491 *
2492 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2493 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2494 *
2495 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2496 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2497 *
2498 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2499 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2500 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2501 *
2502 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2503 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2504 *
2505 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2506 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2507 *
2508 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2509 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2510 * the stack.
2511 *
2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2513 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2514 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2515 *
2516 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2517 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2518 * dtim_period).
2519 *
2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2521 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2522 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2523 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2524 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2525 * only in that case.
2526 *
2527 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2528 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2529 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2530 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2531 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2532 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2533 *
2534 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2535 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2536 * software.
2537 *
2538 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2539 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2540 * active interfaces.
2541 *
2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2543 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2544 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2545 *
2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2547 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2548 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2549 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2550 * supported cipher suites.
2551 *
2552 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2553 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2554 * for frames.
2555 *
2556 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2557 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2558 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2559 * control for more details.
2560 *
2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2562 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2563 *
2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2565 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2566 * is supported.
2567 *
2568 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2569 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2570 *
2571 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2572 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2573 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2574 *
2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2576 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2577 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2578 * CSA frame.
2579 *
2580 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2581 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2582 *
2583 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2584 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2585 *
2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2587 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2588 *
2589 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2590 * within A-MPDU.
2591 *
2592 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2593 * for sent beacons.
2594 *
2595 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2596 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2597 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2598 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2599 *
2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2601 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2602 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2603 * timeout.
2604 *
2605 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2606 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2607 *
2608 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2609 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2610 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2611 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2612 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2613 *
2614 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2615 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2616 *
2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2618 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2619 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2620 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2621 *
2622 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2623 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2624 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2625 *
2626 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2627 * TDLS links.
2628 *
2629 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2630 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2631 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2632 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2633 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2634 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2635 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2636 *
2637 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2638 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2639 *
2640 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2641 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2642 *
2643 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2644 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2645 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2646 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2647 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2648 *
2649 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2650 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2651 * TXQs to start with.
2652 *
2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2654 * length in tx status information
2655 *
2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2657 *
2658 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2659 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2660 *
2661 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2662 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2663 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2664 *
2665 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2666 * offload
2667 *
2668 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2669 * offload
2670 *
2671 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2672 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2673 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2674 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2675 * the stack.
2676 *
2677 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2678 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2679 *
2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2681 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2682 *
2683 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2684 */
2685 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2686 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2687 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2688 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2689 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2690 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2691 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2692 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2693 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2694 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2695 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2696 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2697 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2698 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2699 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2700 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2701 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2702 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2703 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2704 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2705 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2706 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2707 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2708 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2709 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2710 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2711 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2712 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2713 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2714 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2715 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2716 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2717 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2718 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2719 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2720 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2721 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2722 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2723 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2724 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2725 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2726 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2727 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2728 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2729 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2730 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2731 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2732 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2733 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2734 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2735 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2736 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2737 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2738 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2739 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2740
2741 /* keep last, obviously */
2742 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2743 };
2744
2745 /**
2746 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2747 *
2748 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2749 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2750 *
2751 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2752 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2753 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2754 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2755 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2756 *
2757 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2758 *
2759 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2760 * along with this structure.
2761 *
2762 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2763 *
2764 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2765 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2766 *
2767 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2768 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2769 *
2770 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2771 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2772 *
2773 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2774 * that HW supports
2775 *
2776 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2777 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2778 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2779 *
2780 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2781 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2782 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2783 *
2784 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2785 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2786 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2787 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2788 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2789 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2790 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2791 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2792 *
2793 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2794 * can handle.
2795 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2796 * the hw can report back.
2797 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2798 *
2799 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2800 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2801 * aggregation.
2802 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2803 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2804 * it shouldn't be set.
2805 *
2806 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2807 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2808 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2809 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2810 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2811 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2812 *
2813 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2814 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2815 *
2816 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2817 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2818 *
2819 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2820 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2821 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2822 * adding _BW is supported today.
2823 *
2824 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2825 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2826 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2827 *
2828 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2829 *
2830 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2831 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2832 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2833 * device_timestamp.
2834 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2835 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2836 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2837 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2838 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2839 *
2840 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2841 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2842 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2843 *
2844 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2845 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2846 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2847 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2848 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2849 * neither enabled.
2850 *
2851 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2852 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2853 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2854 *
2855 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2856 * device.
2857 *
2858 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2859 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2860 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2861 *
2862 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2863 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2864 *
2865 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2866 *
2867 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2868 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2869 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2870 *
2871 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2872 */
2873 struct ieee80211_hw {
2874 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2875 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2876 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2877 void *priv;
2878 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2879 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2880 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2881 int vif_data_size;
2882 int sta_data_size;
2883 int chanctx_data_size;
2884 int txq_data_size;
2885 u16 queues;
2886 u16 max_listen_interval;
2887 s8 max_signal;
2888 u8 max_rates;
2889 u8 max_report_rates;
2890 u8 max_rate_tries;
2891 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2892 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2893 u8 max_tx_fragments;
2894 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2895 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2896 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2897 struct {
2898 int units_pos;
2899 s16 accuracy;
2900 } radiotap_timestamp;
2901 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2902 u8 uapsd_queues;
2903 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2904 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2905 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2906 u8 weight_multiplier;
2907 u32 max_mtu;
2908 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2909 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2910 };
2911
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2912 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2913 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2914 {
2915 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2916 }
2917 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2918
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2919 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2920 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2921 {
2922 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2923 }
2924 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2925
2926 /**
2927 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2928 *
2929 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2930 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2931 */
2932 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2933 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2934
2935 /* Keep last */
2936 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2937 };
2938
2939 /**
2940 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2941 *
2942 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2943 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2944 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2945 * @status: channel-switch response status
2946 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2947 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2948 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2949 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2950 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2951 */
2952 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2953 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2954 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2955 u8 action_code;
2956 u32 status;
2957 u32 timestamp;
2958 u16 switch_time;
2959 u16 switch_timeout;
2960 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2961 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2962 };
2963
2964 /**
2965 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2966 *
2967 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2968 *
2969 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2970 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2971 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2972 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2973 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2974 *
2975 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2976 */
2977 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2978
2979 /**
2980 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2981 *
2982 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2983 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2984 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2985 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2986 {
2987 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2988 }
2989
2990 /**
2991 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2992 *
2993 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2994 * @addr: the address to set
2995 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)2996 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2997 {
2998 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2999 }
3000
3001 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3002 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3003 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3004 {
3005 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3006 return NULL;
3007 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3008 }
3009
3010 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3011 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3012 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3013 {
3014 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3015 return NULL;
3016 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3017 }
3018
3019 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3020 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3021 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3022 {
3023 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3024 return NULL;
3025 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3026 }
3027
3028 /**
3029 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3030 * @hw: the hardware
3031 * @skb: the skb
3032 *
3033 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3034 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3035 */
3036 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3037
3038 /**
3039 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3040 *
3041 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3042 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3043 *
3044 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3045 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3046 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3047 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3048 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3049 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3050 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3051 *
3052 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3053 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3054 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3055 *
3056 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3057 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3058 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3059 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3060 *
3061 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3062 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3063 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3064 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3065 *
3066 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3067 *
3068 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3069 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3070 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3071 * based on the receive flags.
3072 *
3073 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3074 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3075 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3076 * keys.
3077 *
3078 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3079 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3080 * handler.
3081 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3082 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3083 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3084 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3085 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3086 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3087 *
3088 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3089 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3090 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3091 *
3092 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3093 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3094 * requirements:
3095 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3096 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3097 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3098 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3099 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3100 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3101 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3102 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3103 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3104 */
3105
3106 /**
3107 * DOC: Powersave support
3108 *
3109 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3110 *
3111 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3112 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3113 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3114 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3115 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3116 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3117 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3118 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3119 *
3120 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3121 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3122 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3123 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3124 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3125 *
3126 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3127 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3128 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3129 *
3130 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3131 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3132 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3133 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3134 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3135 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3136 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3137 *
3138 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3139 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3140 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3141 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3142 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3143 * periods.
3144 *
3145 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3146 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3147 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3148 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3149 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3150 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3151 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3152 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3153 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3154 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3155 *
3156 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3157 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3158 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3159 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3160 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3161 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3162 *
3163 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3164 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3165 */
3166
3167 /**
3168 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3169 *
3170 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3171 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3172 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3173 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3174 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3175 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3176 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3177 *
3178 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3179 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3180 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3181 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3182 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3183 *
3184 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3185 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3186 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3187 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3188 *
3189 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3190 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3191 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3192 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3193 *
3194 * - a list of information element IDs
3195 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3196 *
3197 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3198 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3199 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3200 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3201 * vendor information elements.
3202 *
3203 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3204 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3205 *
3206 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3207 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3208 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3209 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3210 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3211 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3212 *
3213 *
3214 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3215 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3216 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3217 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3218 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3219 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3220 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3221 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3222 *
3223 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3224 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3225 * signal strength threshold checking.
3226 */
3227
3228 /**
3229 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3230 *
3231 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3232 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3233 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3234 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3235 *
3236 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3237 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3238 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3239 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3240 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3241 * hardware flags.
3242 *
3243 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3244 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3245 * turned off otherwise.
3246 *
3247 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3248 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3249 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3250 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3251 */
3252
3253 /**
3254 * DOC: Frame filtering
3255 *
3256 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3257 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3258 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3259 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3260 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3261 *
3262 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3263 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3264 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3265 *
3266 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3267 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3268 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3269 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3270 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3271 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3272 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3273 *
3274 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3275 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3276 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3277 * or dropped.
3278 *
3279 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3280 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3281 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3282 * the flag, but not clear it.
3283 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3284 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3285 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3286 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3287 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3288 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3289 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3290 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3291 */
3292
3293 /**
3294 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3295 *
3296 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3297 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3298 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3299 *
3300 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3301 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3302 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3303 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3304 * the driver code.
3305 *
3306 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3307 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3308 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3309 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3310 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3311 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3312 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3313 *
3314 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3315 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3316 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3317 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3318 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3319 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3320 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3321 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3322 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3323 * @sta_notify callback.
3324 *
3325 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3326 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3327 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3328 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3329 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3330 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3331 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3332 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3333 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3334 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3335 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3336 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3337 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3338 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3339 *
3340 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3341 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3342 *
3343 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3344 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3345 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3346 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3347 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3348 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3349 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3350 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3351 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3352 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3353 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3354 *
3355 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3356 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3357 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3358 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3359 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3360 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3361 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3362 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3363 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3364 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3365 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3366 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3367 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3368 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3369 *
3370 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3371 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3372 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3373 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3374 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3375 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3376 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3377 *
3378 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3379 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3380 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3381 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3382 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3383 *
3384 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3385 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3386 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3387 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3388 */
3389
3390 /**
3391 * DOC: HW queue control
3392 *
3393 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3394 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3395 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3396 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3397 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3398 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3399 *
3400 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3401 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3402 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3403 *
3404 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3405 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3406 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3407 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3408 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3409 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3410 * the hardware queue.
3411 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3412 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3413 *
3414 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3415 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3416 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3417 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3418 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3419 *
3420 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3421 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3422 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3423 * off-channel queue: 9
3424 *
3425 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3426 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3427 *
3428 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3429 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3430 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3431 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3432 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3433 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3434 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3435 *
3436 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3437 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3438 *
3439 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3440 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3441 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3442 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3443 */
3444
3445 /**
3446 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3447 *
3448 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3449 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3450 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3451 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3452 *
3453 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3454 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3455 * multicast address.
3456 *
3457 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3458 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3459 *
3460 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3461 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3462 *
3463 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3464 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3465 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3466 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3467 * honour this flag if possible.
3468 *
3469 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3470 * station
3471 *
3472 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3473 *
3474 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3475 *
3476 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3477 *
3478 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3479 */
3480 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3481 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3482 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3483 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3484 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3485 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3486 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3487 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3488 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3489 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3490 };
3491
3492 /**
3493 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3494 *
3495 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3496 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3497 *
3498 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3499 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3500 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3501 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3502 *
3503 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3504 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3505 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3506 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3507 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3508 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3509 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3510 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3511 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3512 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3513 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3514 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3515 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3516 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3517 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3518 * session is gone and removes the station.
3519 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3520 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3521 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3522 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3523 */
3524 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3525 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3526 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3527 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3528 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3529 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3530 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3531 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3532 };
3533
3534 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3535 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3536
3537 /**
3538 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3539 *
3540 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3541 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3542 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3543 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3544 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3545 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3546 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3547 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3548 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3549 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3550 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3551 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3552 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3553 */
3554 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3555 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3556 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3557 u16 tid;
3558 u16 ssn;
3559 u16 buf_size;
3560 bool amsdu;
3561 u16 timeout;
3562 };
3563
3564 /**
3565 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3566 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3567 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3568 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3569 */
3570 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3571 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3572 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3573 };
3574
3575 /**
3576 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3577 *
3578 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3579 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3580 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3581 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3582 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3583 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3584 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3585 * the peer.
3586 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3587 * by the peer
3588 */
3589 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3590 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3591 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3592 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3593 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3594 };
3595
3596 /**
3597 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3598 *
3599 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3600 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3601 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3602 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3603 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3604 *
3605 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3606 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3607 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3608 */
3609 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3610 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3611 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3612 };
3613
3614 /**
3615 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3616 *
3617 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3618 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3619 *
3620 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3621 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3622 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3623 * of wowlan configuration)
3624 */
3625 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3626 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3627 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3628 };
3629
3630 /**
3631 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3632 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3633 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3634 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3635 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3636 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3637 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3638 */
3639 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3640 u16 duration;
3641 u16 subtype;
3642 u8 success:1;
3643 };
3644
3645 /**
3646 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3647 *
3648 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3649 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3650 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3651 *
3652 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3653 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3654 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3655 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3656 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3657 * Must be atomic.
3658 *
3659 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3660 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3661 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3662 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3663 * or zero.
3664 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3665 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3666 * is added.
3667 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3668 *
3669 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3670 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3671 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3672 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3673 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3674 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3675 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3676 *
3677 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3678 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3679 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3680 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3681 * reconfigured at resume time.
3682 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3683 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3684 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3685 * must return 1 from this function.
3686 *
3687 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3688 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3689 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3690 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3691 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3692 *
3693 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3694 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3695 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3696 * in suspend().
3697 *
3698 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3699 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3700 * and @stop must be implemented.
3701 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3702 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3703 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3704 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3705 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3706 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3707 *
3708 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3709 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3710 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3711 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3712 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3713 *
3714 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3715 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3716 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3717 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3718 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3719 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3720 * MAC address of the device going away.
3721 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3722 *
3723 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3724 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3725 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3726 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3727 *
3728 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3729 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3730 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3731 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3732 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3733 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3734 * can sleep.
3735 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3736 * are not implemented.
3737 *
3738 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3739 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3740 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3741 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3742 * The callback can sleep.
3743 *
3744 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3745 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3746 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3747 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3748 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3749 * non-MLO connections.
3750 * The callback can sleep.
3751 *
3752 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3753 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3754 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3755 *
3756 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3757 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3758 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3759 *
3760 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3761 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3762 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3763 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3764 * which flags are changed.
3765 * This callback can sleep.
3766 *
3767 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3768 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3769 *
3770 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3771 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3772 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3773 * is enabled.
3774 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3775 * The callback can sleep.
3776 *
3777 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3778 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3779 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3780 * The callback must be atomic.
3781 *
3782 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3783 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3784 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3785 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3786 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3787 *
3788 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3789 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3790 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3791 *
3792 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3793 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3794 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3795 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3796 * that power save is disabled.
3797 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3798 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3799 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3800 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3801 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3802 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3803 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3804 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3805 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3806 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3807 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3808 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3809 * The callback can sleep.
3810 *
3811 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3812 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3813 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3814 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3815 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3816 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3817 * The callback can sleep.
3818 *
3819 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3820 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
3821 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3822 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3823 *
3824 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3825 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3826 *
3827 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3828 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3829 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3830 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3831 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3832 *
3833 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3834 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3835 * this notification.
3836 * The callback can sleep.
3837 *
3838 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3839 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
3840 * The callback can sleep.
3841 *
3842 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3843 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3844 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3845 * The callback must be atomic.
3846 *
3847 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3848 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3849 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3850 * should be set as well.
3851 * The callback can sleep.
3852 *
3853 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3854 * The callback can sleep.
3855 *
3856 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3857 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3858 *
3859 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3860 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3861 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3862 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3863 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3864 * This callback can sleep.
3865 *
3866 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3867 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3868 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3869 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3870 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3871 *
3872 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3873 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3874 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3875 * callback can sleep.
3876 *
3877 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3878 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3879 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3880 * callback can sleep.
3881 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3882 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3883 *
3884 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3885 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3886 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3887 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3888 *
3889 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3890 * power for the station.
3891 * This callback can sleep.
3892 *
3893 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3894 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3895 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3896 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3897 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3898 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3899 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3900 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3901 * The callback can sleep.
3902 *
3903 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3904 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3905 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3906 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3907 * in @sta_state.
3908 * The callback can sleep.
3909 *
3910 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3911 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3912 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3913 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3914 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3915 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3916 * Must be atomic.
3917 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3918 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3919 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3920 *
3921 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3922 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3923 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3924 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3925 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3926 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3927 * The callback can sleep.
3928 *
3929 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3930 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3931 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3932 * The callback can sleep.
3933 *
3934 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3935 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3936 * required function.
3937 * The callback can sleep.
3938 *
3939 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3940 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3941 * required function.
3942 * The callback can sleep.
3943 *
3944 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3945 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3946 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3947 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3948 * The callback can sleep.
3949 *
3950 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3951 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3952 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3953 * TSF synchronization.
3954 * The callback can sleep.
3955 *
3956 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3957 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3958 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3959 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3960 * The callback can sleep.
3961 *
3962 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3963 *
3964 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3965 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3966 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3967 * The callback can sleep.
3968 *
3969 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3970 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3971 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3972 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3973 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3974 *
3975 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3976 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3977 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3978 *
3979 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3980 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3981 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3982 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3983 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3984 * Note that vif can be NULL.
3985 * The callback can sleep.
3986 *
3987 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
3988 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
3989 * The callback can sleep.
3990 *
3991 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3992 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3993 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3994 * completion of the channel switch.
3995 *
3996 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3997 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3998 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3999 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4000 *
4001 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4002 *
4003 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4004 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4005 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4006 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4007 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4008 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4009 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4010 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4011 * must be accepted in this case.
4012 * This callback may sleep.
4013 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4014 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4015 *
4016 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4017 *
4018 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4019 *
4020 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4021 * queues before entering power save.
4022 *
4023 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4024 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4025 * The callback can sleep.
4026 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4027 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4028 * The callback must be atomic.
4029 *
4030 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4031 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4032 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4033 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4034 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4035 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4036 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4037 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4038 * more-data bit must always be set.
4039 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4040 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4041 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4042 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4043 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4044 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4045 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4046 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4047 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4048 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4049 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4050 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4051 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4052 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4053 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4054 * This callback must be atomic.
4055 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4056 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4057 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4058 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4059 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4060 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4061 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4062 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4063 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4064 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4065 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4066 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4067 * This callback must be atomic.
4068 *
4069 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4070 *
4071 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4072 *
4073 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4074 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4075 *
4076 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4077 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4078 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4079 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4080 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4081 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4082 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4083 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4084 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4085 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4086 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4087 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4088 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4089 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4090 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4091 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4092 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4093 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4094 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4095 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4096 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4097 *
4098 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4099 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4100 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4101 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4102 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4103 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4104 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4105 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4106 *
4107 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4108 * This callback may sleep.
4109 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4110 * This callback may sleep.
4111 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4112 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4113 * channel context with different settings
4114 * This callback may sleep.
4115 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4116 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4117 * This callback may sleep.
4118 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4119 * unbound from vif.
4120 * This callback may sleep.
4121 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4122 * another, as specified in the list of
4123 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4124 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4125 * This callback may sleep.
4126 *
4127 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4128 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4129 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4130 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4131 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4132 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4133 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4134 *
4135 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4136 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4137 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4138 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4139 * This callback may sleep.
4140 *
4141 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4142 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4143 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4144 *
4145 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4146 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4147 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4148 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4149 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4150 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4151 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4152 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4153 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4154 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4155 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4156 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4157 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4158 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4159 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4160 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4161 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4162 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4163 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4164 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4165 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4166 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4167 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4168 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4169 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4170 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4171 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4172 *
4173 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4174 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4175 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4176 *
4177 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4178 * and hardware limits.
4179 *
4180 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4181 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4182 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4183 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4184 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4185 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4186 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4187 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4188 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4189 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4190 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4191 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4192 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4193 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4194 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4195 * the function call.
4196 *
4197 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4198 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4199 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4200 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4201 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4202 *
4203 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4204 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4205 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4206 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4207 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4208 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4209 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4210 * changed parameters.
4211 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4212 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4213 * this call.
4214 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4215 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4216 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4217 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4218 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4219 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4220 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4221 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4222 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4223 *
4224 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4225 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4226 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4227 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4228 * This callback may sleep.
4229 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4230 * This callback may sleep.
4231 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4232 * 4-address mode
4233 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4234 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4235 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4236 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4237 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4238 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4239 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4240 * twt structure.
4241 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4242 * from the peer.
4243 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4244 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4245 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4246 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4247 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4248 * radar channel.
4249 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4250 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4251 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4252 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4253 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4254 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4255 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4256 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4257 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4258 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4259 * This callback can sleep.
4260 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4261 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4262 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4263 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4264 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4265 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4266 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4267 * that.
4268 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4269 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4270 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4271 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4272 */
4273 struct ieee80211_ops {
4274 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4275 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4276 struct sk_buff *skb);
4277 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4278 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4279 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4280 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4281 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4282 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4283 #endif
4284 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4285 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4286 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4288 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4289 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4290 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4291 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4292 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4293 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4294 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4295 u64 changed);
4296 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4297 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4298 u64 changed);
4299 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4300 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4301 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4302 u64 changed);
4303
4304 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4305 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4306 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4307 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4308
4309 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4310 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4311 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4312 unsigned int changed_flags,
4313 unsigned int *total_flags,
4314 u64 multicast);
4315 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4316 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4317 unsigned int filter_flags,
4318 unsigned int changed_flags);
4319 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4320 bool set);
4321 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4322 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4323 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4324 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4325 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4326 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4327 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4328 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4329 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4330 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4331 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4332 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4333 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4334 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4335 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4336 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4337 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4338 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4339 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4340 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4341 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4342 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4343 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4344 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4346 const u8 *mac_addr);
4347 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4349 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4350 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4351 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4352 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4353 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4354 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4355 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4356 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4357 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4358 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4359 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4360 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4361 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4363 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4364 struct dentry *dir);
4365 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4366 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4367 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4368 struct dentry *dir);
4369 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4370 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4371 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4372 struct dentry *dir);
4373 #endif
4374 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4376 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4377 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4378 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4379 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4381 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4382 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4383 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4384 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4385 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4386 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4387 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4388 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4389 u32 changed);
4390 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4391 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4392 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4393 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4396 struct station_info *sinfo);
4397 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4399 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4400 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4401 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4402 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4403 u64 tsf);
4404 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4405 s64 offset);
4406 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4407 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4408
4409 /**
4410 * @ampdu_action:
4411 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4412 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4413 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4414 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4415 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4416 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4417 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4418 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4419 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4420 *
4421 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4422 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4423 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4424 *
4425 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4426 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4427 *
4428 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4429 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4430 * - ``TX: 81``
4431 *
4432 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4433 *
4434 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4435 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4436 * if the session can start immediately.
4437 *
4438 * The callback can sleep.
4439 */
4440 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4442 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4443 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4444 struct survey_info *survey);
4445 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4446 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4447 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4448 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4449 void *data, int len);
4450 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4451 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4452 void *data, int len);
4453 #endif
4454 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455 u32 queues, bool drop);
4456 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4457 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4458 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4459 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4460 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4461 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4462 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4463
4464 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4466 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4467 int duration,
4468 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4469 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4470 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4471 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4472 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4474 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4475 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4476 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4477 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4478 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4479 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4480
4481 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4483 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4484 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4485 bool more_data);
4486 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4488 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4489 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4490 bool more_data);
4491
4492 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4493 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4494 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4497 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4500
4501 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4503 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4504 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4505 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4506 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4507
4508 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4510
4511 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4513 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4515 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4517 u32 changed);
4518 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4521 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4522 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4525 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4526 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4528 int n_vifs,
4529 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4530
4531 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4533
4534 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4535 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4537 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4538 #endif
4539 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4542 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4545
4546 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4548 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4549 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4550 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4552 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4553
4554 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4555 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4556 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4558 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559 int *dbm);
4560
4561 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4562 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4563 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4564 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4565 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4566 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4567 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4568 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4569 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4572
4573 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4575 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4576
4577 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4580 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4581 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4582 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4583 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4584 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4585 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4588 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590 u8 instance_id);
4591 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 struct sk_buff *head,
4593 struct sk_buff *skb);
4594 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4597 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4598 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4599 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4601 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4603 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4604 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4605 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4608 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4610 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4611 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4612 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4613 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4614 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4615 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4616 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4617 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4619 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4620 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4621 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4622 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4624 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4625 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4626 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4627 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4628 struct net_device_path *path);
4629 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4631 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4632 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4633 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4636 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4637 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4639 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4640 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4641 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4642 struct net_device *dev,
4643 enum tc_setup_type type,
4644 void *type_data);
4645 };
4646
4647 /**
4648 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4649 *
4650 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4651 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4652 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4653 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4654 * @priv_data_len.
4655 *
4656 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4657 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4658 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4659 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4660 *
4661 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4662 */
4663 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4664 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4665 const char *requested_name);
4666
4667 /**
4668 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4669 *
4670 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4671 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4672 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4673 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4674 * @priv_data_len.
4675 *
4676 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4677 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4678 *
4679 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4680 */
4681 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4682 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4683 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4684 {
4685 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4686 }
4687
4688 /**
4689 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4690 *
4691 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4692 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4693 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4694 *
4695 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4696 *
4697 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4698 */
4699 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4700
4701 /**
4702 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4703 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4704 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4705 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4706 */
4707 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4708 int throughput;
4709 int blink_time;
4710 };
4711
4712 /**
4713 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4714 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4715 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4716 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4717 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4718 */
4719 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4720 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4721 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4722 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4723 };
4724
4725 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4726 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4727 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4728 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4729 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4730 const char *
4731 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4732 unsigned int flags,
4733 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4734 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4735 #endif
4736 /**
4737 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4738 *
4739 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4740 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4741 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4742 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4743 *
4744 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4745 *
4746 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4747 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4748 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4749 {
4750 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4751 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4752 #else
4753 return NULL;
4754 #endif
4755 }
4756
4757 /**
4758 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4759 *
4760 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4761 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4762 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4763 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4764 *
4765 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4766 *
4767 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4768 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4769 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4770 {
4771 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4772 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4773 #else
4774 return NULL;
4775 #endif
4776 }
4777
4778 /**
4779 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4780 *
4781 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4782 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4783 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4784 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4785 *
4786 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4787 *
4788 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4789 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4790 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4791 {
4792 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4793 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4794 #else
4795 return NULL;
4796 #endif
4797 }
4798
4799 /**
4800 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4801 *
4802 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4803 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4804 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4805 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4806 *
4807 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4808 *
4809 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4810 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4811 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4812 {
4813 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4814 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4815 #else
4816 return NULL;
4817 #endif
4818 }
4819
4820 /**
4821 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4822 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4823 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4824 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4825 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4826 *
4827 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4828 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4829 *
4830 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4831 */
4832 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4833 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4834 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4835 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4836 {
4837 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4838 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4839 blink_table_len);
4840 #else
4841 return NULL;
4842 #endif
4843 }
4844
4845 /**
4846 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4847 *
4848 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4849 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4850 *
4851 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4852 */
4853 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4854
4855 /**
4856 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4857 *
4858 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4859 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4860 * before calling this function.
4861 *
4862 * @hw: the hardware to free
4863 */
4864 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4865
4866 /**
4867 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4868 *
4869 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4870 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4871 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4872 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4873 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4874 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4875 *
4876 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4877 */
4878 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4879
4880 /**
4881 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4882 *
4883 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4884 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4885 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4886 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4887 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4888 *
4889 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4890 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4891 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4892 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4893 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4894 *
4895 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4896 *
4897 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4898 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4899 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4900 * @list: the destination list
4901 */
4902 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4903 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4904
4905 /**
4906 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4907 *
4908 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4909 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4910 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4911 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4912 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4913 *
4914 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4915 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4916 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4917 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4918 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4919 *
4920 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4921 *
4922 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4923 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4924 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4925 * @napi: the NAPI context
4926 */
4927 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4928 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4929
4930 /**
4931 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4932 *
4933 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4934 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4935 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4936 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4937 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4938 *
4939 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4940 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4941 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4942 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4943 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4944 *
4945 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4946 *
4947 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4948 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4949 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4950 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4951 {
4952 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4953 }
4954
4955 /**
4956 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4957 *
4958 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4959 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4960 *
4961 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4962 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4963 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4964 *
4965 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4966 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4967 */
4968 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4969
4970 /**
4971 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4972 *
4973 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4974 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4975 *
4976 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4977 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4978 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4979 *
4980 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4981 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4982 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4983 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4984 struct sk_buff *skb)
4985 {
4986 local_bh_disable();
4987 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4988 local_bh_enable();
4989 }
4990
4991 /**
4992 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4993 *
4994 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4995 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4996 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4997 *
4998 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4999 *
5000 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5001 * each other.
5002 *
5003 * @sta: currently connected sta
5004 * @start: start or stop PS
5005 *
5006 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5007 */
5008 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5009
5010 /**
5011 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5012 * (in process context)
5013 *
5014 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5015 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5016 * applies.
5017 *
5018 * @sta: currently connected sta
5019 * @start: start or stop PS
5020 *
5021 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5022 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5023 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5024 bool start)
5025 {
5026 int ret;
5027
5028 local_bh_disable();
5029 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5030 local_bh_enable();
5031
5032 return ret;
5033 }
5034
5035 /**
5036 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5037 * @sta: currently connected station
5038 *
5039 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5040 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5041 * connected station was received.
5042 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5043 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5044 * be serialized.
5045 */
5046 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5047
5048 /**
5049 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5050 * @sta: currently connected station
5051 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5052 *
5053 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5054 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5055 * from a connected station was received.
5056 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5057 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5058 * serialized.
5059 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5060 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5061 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5062 * checks.
5063 */
5064 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5065
5066 /*
5067 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5068 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5069 */
5070 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5071
5072 /**
5073 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5074 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5075 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5076 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5077 *
5078 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5079 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5080 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5081 *
5082 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5083 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5084 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5085 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5086 *
5087 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5088 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5089 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5090 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5091 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5092 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5093 *
5094 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5095 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5096 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5097 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5098 * use this API.
5099 */
5100 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5101 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5102
5103 /**
5104 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5105 *
5106 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5107 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5108 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5109 *
5110 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5111 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5112 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5113 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5114 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5115 */
5116 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5117 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5118 struct sk_buff *skb,
5119 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5120 int max_rates);
5121
5122 /**
5123 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5124 *
5125 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5126 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5127 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5128 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5129 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5130 * slow stations to starve).
5131 *
5132 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5133 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5134 */
5135 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5136 u32 thr);
5137
5138 /**
5139 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5140 *
5141 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5142 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5143 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5144 *
5145 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5146 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5147 * @info: tx status information
5148 */
5149 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5150 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5151 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5152
5153 /**
5154 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5155 *
5156 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5157 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5158 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5159 *
5160 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5161 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5162 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5163 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5164 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5165 *
5166 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5167 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168 */
5169 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170 struct sk_buff *skb);
5171
5172 /**
5173 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5174 *
5175 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5176 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5177 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5178 *
5179 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5180 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5181 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5182 *
5183 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5184 * @status: tx status information
5185 */
5186 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5187 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5188
5189 /**
5190 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5191 *
5192 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5193 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5194 * specific skbs.
5195 *
5196 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5197 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5198 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5199 *
5200 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5201 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5202 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5203 * @info: tx status information
5204 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5205 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5206 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5207 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5208 {
5209 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5210 .sta = sta,
5211 .info = info,
5212 };
5213
5214 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5215 }
5216
5217 /**
5218 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5219 *
5220 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5221 *
5222 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5223 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5224 * for a single hardware.
5225 *
5226 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5227 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5228 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5229 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5230 struct sk_buff *skb)
5231 {
5232 local_bh_disable();
5233 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5234 local_bh_enable();
5235 }
5236
5237 /**
5238 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5239 *
5240 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5241 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5242 *
5243 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5244 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5245 *
5246 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5247 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5248 */
5249 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5250 struct sk_buff *skb);
5251
5252 /**
5253 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5254 *
5255 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5256 * connected STA.
5257 *
5258 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5259 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5260 */
5261 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5262
5263 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5264
5265 /**
5266 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5267 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5268 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5269 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5270 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5271 * should be ignored.
5272 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5273 */
5274 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5275 u16 tim_offset;
5276 u16 tim_length;
5277
5278 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5279 u16 mbssid_off;
5280 };
5281
5282 /**
5283 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5284 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5285 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5286 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5287 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5288 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5289 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5290 *
5291 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5292 * obtain the beacon template.
5293 *
5294 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5295 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5296 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5297 * applicable, the CSA count.
5298 *
5299 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5300 *
5301 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5302 */
5303 struct sk_buff *
5304 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5305 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5306 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5307 unsigned int link_id);
5308
5309 /**
5310 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5311 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5312 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5313 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5314 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5315 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5316 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5317 *
5318 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5319 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5320 * requested index.
5321 *
5322 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5323 */
5324 struct sk_buff *
5325 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5326 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5327 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5328 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5329
5330 /**
5331 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5332 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5333 *
5334 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5335 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5336 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5337 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5338 */
5339 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5340 u8 cnt;
5341 struct {
5342 struct sk_buff *skb;
5343 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5344 } bcn[];
5345 };
5346
5347 /**
5348 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5349 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5350 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5351 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5352 *
5353 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5354 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5355 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5356 * one multiple BSSID element.
5357 *
5358 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5359 *
5360 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5361 * %NULL on error.
5362 */
5363 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5364 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5366 unsigned int link_id);
5367
5368 /**
5369 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5370 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5371 *
5372 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5373 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5374 */
5375 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5376
5377 /**
5378 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5379 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5380 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5381 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5382 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5383 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5384 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5385 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5386 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5387 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5388 *
5389 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5390 * obtain the beacon frame.
5391 *
5392 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5393 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5394 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5395 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5396 *
5397 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5398 *
5399 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5400 */
5401 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5402 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5403 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5404 unsigned int link_id);
5405
5406 /**
5407 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5408 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5409 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5410 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5411 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5412 *
5413 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5414 *
5415 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5416 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5417 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5418 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5419 unsigned int link_id)
5420 {
5421 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5422 }
5423
5424 /**
5425 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5427 *
5428 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5429 * This function is called implicitly when
5430 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5431 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5432 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5433 *
5434 * Return: new countdown value
5435 */
5436 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5437
5438 /**
5439 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5441 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5442 *
5443 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5444 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5445 *
5446 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5447 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5448 */
5449 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5450
5451 /**
5452 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5453 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5454 *
5455 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5456 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5457 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5458 */
5459 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5460
5461 /**
5462 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5463 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5464 *
5465 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5466 */
5467 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5468
5469 /**
5470 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5471 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5472 *
5473 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5474 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5475 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5476 */
5477 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5478
5479 /**
5480 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5481 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5482 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5483 *
5484 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5485 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5486 *
5487 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5488 *
5489 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5490 */
5491 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5492 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5493
5494 /**
5495 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5496 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5497 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5498 *
5499 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5500 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5501 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5502 *
5503 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5504 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5505 *
5506 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5507 */
5508 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5510
5511 /**
5512 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5513 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5514 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5515 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5516 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5517 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5518 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5519 * if at all possible
5520 *
5521 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5522 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5523 * BSSID and address is used.
5524 *
5525 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5526 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5527 *
5528 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5529 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5530 *
5531 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5532 */
5533 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5534 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5535 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5536
5537 /**
5538 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5539 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5540 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5541 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5542 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5543 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5544 *
5545 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5546 * hardware.
5547 *
5548 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5549 */
5550 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5551 const u8 *src_addr,
5552 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5553 size_t tailroom);
5554
5555 /**
5556 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5557 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5558 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5559 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5560 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5561 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5562 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5563 *
5564 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5565 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5566 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5567 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5568 */
5569 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5570 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5571 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5572 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5573
5574 /**
5575 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5576 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5577 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5578 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5579 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5580 *
5581 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5582 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5583 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5584 *
5585 * Return: The duration.
5586 */
5587 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5588 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5589 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5590
5591 /**
5592 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5593 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5594 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5595 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5596 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5597 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5598 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5599 *
5600 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5601 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5602 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5603 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5604 */
5605 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5607 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5608 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5609 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5610
5611 /**
5612 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5613 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5614 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5615 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5616 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5617 *
5618 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5619 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5620 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5621 *
5622 * Return: The duration.
5623 */
5624 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5625 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5626 size_t frame_len,
5627 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5628
5629 /**
5630 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5631 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5632 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5633 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5634 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5635 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5636 *
5637 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5638 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5639 *
5640 * Return: The duration.
5641 */
5642 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5643 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5644 enum nl80211_band band,
5645 size_t frame_len,
5646 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5647
5648 /**
5649 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5650 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5651 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5652 *
5653 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5654 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5655 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5656 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5657 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5658 *
5659 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5660 * frames are available.
5661 *
5662 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5663 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5664 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5665 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5666 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5667 * use common code for all beacons.
5668 */
5669 struct sk_buff *
5670 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5671
5672 /**
5673 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5674 *
5675 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5676 *
5677 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5678 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5679 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5680 */
5681 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5682 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5683
5684 /**
5685 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5686 *
5687 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5688 * from the given packet.
5689 *
5690 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5691 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5692 * with this P1K
5693 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5694 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5695 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5696 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5697 {
5698 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5699 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5700 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5701
5702 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5703 }
5704
5705 /**
5706 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5707 *
5708 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5709 * and transmitter address.
5710 *
5711 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5712 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5713 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5714 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5715 */
5716 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5717 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5718
5719 /**
5720 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5721 *
5722 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5723 * in the packet.
5724 *
5725 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5726 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5727 * encrypted with this key
5728 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5729 */
5730 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5731 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5732
5733 /**
5734 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5735 *
5736 * @pos: start of crypto header
5737 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5738 * @pn: PN to add
5739 *
5740 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5741 * the packet payload)
5742 *
5743 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5744 * point to the crypto header)
5745 */
5746 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5747
5748 /**
5749 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5750 *
5751 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5752 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5753 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5754 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5755 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5756 *
5757 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5758 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5759 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5760 *
5761 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5762 * can be done concurrently.
5763 */
5764 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5765 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5766
5767 /**
5768 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5769 *
5770 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5771 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5772 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5773 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5774 * @seq: new sequence data
5775 *
5776 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5777 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5778 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5779 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5780 *
5781 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5782 * can be done concurrently.
5783 */
5784 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5785 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5786
5787 /**
5788 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5789 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5790 *
5791 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5792 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5793 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5794 *
5795 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5796 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5797 */
5798 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5799
5800 /**
5801 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5802 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5803 * @keyconf: new key data
5804 *
5805 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5806 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5807 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5808 *
5809 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5810 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5811 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5812 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5813 *
5814 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5815 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5816 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5817 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5818 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5819 * of the reconfiguration.
5820 *
5821 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5822 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5823 *
5824 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5825 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5826 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5827 * the key that's being replaced.
5828 */
5829 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5830 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5831 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5832
5833 /**
5834 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5835 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5836 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5837 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5838 * @gfp: allocation flags
5839 */
5840 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5841 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5842
5843 /**
5844 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5845 *
5846 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5847 * at the same time.
5848 *
5849 * @keyconf: the key in question
5850 */
5851 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5852
5853 /**
5854 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5855 *
5856 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5857 * at the same time.
5858 *
5859 * @keyconf: the key in question
5860 */
5861 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5862
5863 /**
5864 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5865 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5866 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5867 *
5868 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5869 */
5870 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5871
5872 /**
5873 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5874 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5875 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5876 *
5877 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5878 */
5879 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5880
5881 /**
5882 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5883 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5884 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5885 *
5886 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5887 *
5888 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5889 */
5890
5891 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5892
5893 /**
5894 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5895 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5896 *
5897 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5898 */
5899 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5900
5901 /**
5902 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5903 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5904 *
5905 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5906 */
5907 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5908
5909 /**
5910 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5911 *
5912 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5913 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5914 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5915 * any context, including hardirq context.
5916 *
5917 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5918 * @info: information about the completed scan
5919 */
5920 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5921 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5922
5923 /**
5924 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5925 *
5926 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5927 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5928 *
5929 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5930 */
5931 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5932
5933 /**
5934 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5935 *
5936 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5937 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5938 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5939 * while associating, for instance.
5940 *
5941 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5942 */
5943 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5944
5945 /**
5946 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5947 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5948 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5949 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5950 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5951 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5952 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5953 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5954 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5955 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5956 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5957 * for instance.
5958 */
5959 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5960 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
5961 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
5962 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
5963 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
5964 };
5965
5966 /**
5967 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5968 *
5969 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5970 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5971 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5972 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5973 *
5974 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5975 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5976 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5977 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5978 */
5979 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5980 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5981 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5982 void *data);
5983
5984 /**
5985 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5986 *
5987 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5988 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5989 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5990 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5991 * be used.
5992 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5993 *
5994 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5995 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5996 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5997 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5998 */
5999 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6000 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6001 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6002 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6003 void *data)
6004 {
6005 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6006 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6007 iterator, data);
6008 }
6009
6010 /**
6011 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6012 *
6013 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6014 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6015 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6016 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6017 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6018 *
6019 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6020 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6021 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6022 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6023 */
6024 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6025 u32 iter_flags,
6026 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6027 u8 *mac,
6028 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6029 void *data);
6030
6031 /**
6032 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6033 *
6034 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6035 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6036 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6037 *
6038 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6039 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6040 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6041 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6042 */
6043 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6044 u32 iter_flags,
6045 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6046 u8 *mac,
6047 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6048 void *data);
6049
6050 /**
6051 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6052 *
6053 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6054 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6055 * function for them.
6056 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6057 *
6058 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6059 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6060 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6061 */
6062 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6063 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6064 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6065 void *data);
6066 /**
6067 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6068 *
6069 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6070 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6071 *
6072 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6073 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6074 */
6075 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6076
6077 /**
6078 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6079 *
6080 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6081 * workqueue.
6082 *
6083 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6084 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6085 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6086 */
6087 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6088 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6089 unsigned long delay);
6090
6091 /**
6092 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6093 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6094 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6095 *
6096 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6097 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6098 * mac80211.
6099 *
6100 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6101 */
6102 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6103 u16 tid);
6104
6105 /**
6106 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6107 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6108 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6109 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6110 *
6111 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6112 *
6113 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6114 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6115 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6116 */
6117 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6118 u16 timeout);
6119
6120 /**
6121 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6122 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6123 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6124 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6125 *
6126 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6127 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6128 * from any context.
6129 */
6130 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6131 u16 tid);
6132
6133 /**
6134 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6135 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6136 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6137 *
6138 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6139 *
6140 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6141 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6142 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6143 */
6144 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6145
6146 /**
6147 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6148 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6149 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6150 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6151 *
6152 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6153 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6154 * can be called from any context.
6155 */
6156 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6157 u16 tid);
6158
6159 /**
6160 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6161 *
6162 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6163 * @addr: station's address
6164 *
6165 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6166 *
6167 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6168 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6169 */
6170 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6171 const u8 *addr);
6172
6173 /**
6174 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6175 *
6176 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6177 * @addr: remote station's address
6178 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6179 *
6180 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6181 *
6182 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6183 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6184 *
6185 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6186 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6187 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6188 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6189 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6190 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6191 * is not reliable.
6192 *
6193 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6194 */
6195 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6196 const u8 *addr,
6197 const u8 *localaddr);
6198
6199 /**
6200 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6201 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6202 * @addr: remote station's link address
6203 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6204 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6205 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6206 *
6207 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6208 */
6209 struct ieee80211_sta *
6210 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6211 const u8 *addr,
6212 const u8 *localaddr,
6213 unsigned int *link_id);
6214
6215 /**
6216 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6217 * @hw: the hardware
6218 * @pubsta: the station
6219 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6220 *
6221 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6222 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6223 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6224 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6225 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6226 *
6227 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6228 * manner.
6229 *
6230 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6231 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6232 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6233 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6234 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6235 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6236 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6237 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6238 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6239 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6240 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6241 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6242 * woke up while blocked or not.
6243 */
6244 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6245 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6246
6247 /**
6248 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6249 * @pubsta: the station
6250 *
6251 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6252 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6253 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6254 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6255 *
6256 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6257 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6258 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6259 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6260 *
6261 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6262 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6263 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6264 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6265 */
6266 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6267
6268 /**
6269 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6270 * @pubsta: the station
6271 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6272 *
6273 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6274 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6275 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6276 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6277 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6278 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6279 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6280 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6281 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6282 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6283 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6284 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6285 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6286 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6287 */
6288 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6289
6290 /**
6291 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6292 * @pubsta: the station
6293 *
6294 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6295 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6296 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6297 *
6298 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6299 * there is no need to call this function.
6300 */
6301 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6302
6303 /**
6304 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6305 *
6306 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6307 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6308 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6309 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6310 *
6311 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6312 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6313 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6314 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6315 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6316 * attempts.
6317 *
6318 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6319 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6320 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6321 * them to 0.
6322 *
6323 * @pubsta: the station
6324 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6325 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6326 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6327 */
6328 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6329 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6330
6331 /**
6332 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6333 *
6334 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6335 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6336 *
6337 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6338 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6339 */
6340 bool
6341 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6342
6343 /**
6344 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6345 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6346 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6347 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6348 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6349 *
6350 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6351 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6352 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6353 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6354 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6355 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6356 *
6357 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6358 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6359 * set_key callback.
6360 */
6361 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6363 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6364 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6365 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6366 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6367 void *data),
6368 void *iter_data);
6369
6370 /**
6371 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6372 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6373 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6374 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6375 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6376 *
6377 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6378 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6379 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6380 * in removal process will be skipped.
6381 *
6382 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6383 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6384 */
6385 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6386 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6387 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6388 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6389 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6390 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6391 void *data),
6392 void *iter_data);
6393
6394 /**
6395 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6396 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6397 * @iter: iterator function
6398 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6399 *
6400 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6401 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6402 * places while calling into the driver.
6403 *
6404 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6405 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6406 * removed.
6407 *
6408 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6409 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6410 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6411 * or not.
6412 */
6413 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6414 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6415 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6416 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6417 void *data),
6418 void *iter_data);
6419
6420 /**
6421 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6422 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6423 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6424 *
6425 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6426 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6427 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6428 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6429 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6430 * %NULL.
6431 *
6432 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6433 */
6434 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6436
6437 /**
6438 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6439 *
6440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6441 *
6442 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6443 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6444 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6445 */
6446 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6447
6448 /**
6449 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6450 *
6451 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6452 *
6453 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6454 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6455 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6456 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6457 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6458 *
6459 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6460 * without connection recovery attempts.
6461 */
6462 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6463
6464 /**
6465 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6466 *
6467 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6468 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6469 *
6470 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6471 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6472 */
6473 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6474
6475 /**
6476 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6477 *
6478 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6479 *
6480 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6481 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6482 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6483 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6484 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6485 *
6486 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6487 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6488 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6489 * disconnect normally later.
6490 *
6491 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6492 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6493 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6494 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6495 */
6496 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6497
6498 /**
6499 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6500 * hardware restart
6501 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6502 *
6503 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6504 * hardware restart.
6505 */
6506 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6507
6508 /**
6509 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6510 * rssi threshold triggered
6511 *
6512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6513 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6514 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6515 * @gfp: context flags
6516 *
6517 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6518 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6519 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6520 */
6521 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6522 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6523 s32 rssi_level,
6524 gfp_t gfp);
6525
6526 /**
6527 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6528 *
6529 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6530 * @gfp: context flags
6531 */
6532 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6533
6534 /**
6535 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6536 *
6537 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6538 */
6539 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6540
6541 /**
6542 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6543 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6544 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6545 *
6546 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6547 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6548 */
6549 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6550
6551 /**
6552 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6553 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6554 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6555 *
6556 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6557 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6558 * a deauth frame in this case.
6559 */
6560 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6561 bool block_tx);
6562
6563 /**
6564 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6565 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6566 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6567 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6568 *
6569 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6570 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6571 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6572 */
6573 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6574 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6575
6576 /**
6577 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6578 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6579 */
6580 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6581
6582 /**
6583 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6584 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6585 */
6586 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6587
6588 /**
6589 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6590 *
6591 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6592 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6593 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6594 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6595 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6596 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6597 *
6598 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6599 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6600 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6601 */
6602 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6603 const u8 *addr);
6604
6605 /**
6606 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6607 * @pubsta: station struct
6608 * @tid: the session's TID
6609 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6610 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6611 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6612 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6613 *
6614 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6615 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6616 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6617 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6618 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6619 */
6620 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6621 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6622 u16 received_mpdus);
6623
6624 /**
6625 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6626 *
6627 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6628 * buffer.
6629 *
6630 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6631 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6632 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6633 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6634 */
6635 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6636
6637 /**
6638 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6639 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6640 * @addr: station mac address
6641 * @tid: the rx tid
6642 */
6643 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6644 unsigned int tid);
6645
6646 /**
6647 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6648 *
6649 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6650 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6651 * reordering.
6652 *
6653 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6654 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6655 *
6656 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6657 * @addr: station mac address
6658 * @tid: the rx tid
6659 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6660 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6661 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6662 {
6663 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6664 return;
6665 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6666 }
6667
6668 /**
6669 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6670 *
6671 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6672 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6673 * reordering.
6674 *
6675 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6676 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6677 *
6678 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6679 * @addr: station mac address
6680 * @tid: the rx tid
6681 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6682 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6683 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6684 {
6685 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6686 return;
6687 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6688 }
6689
6690 /**
6691 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6692 *
6693 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6694 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6695 *
6696 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6697 *
6698 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6699 * @addr: station mac address
6700 * @tid: the rx tid
6701 */
6702 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6703 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6704
6705 /* Rate control API */
6706
6707 /**
6708 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6709 *
6710 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6711 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6712 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6713 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6714 * to be filled in
6715 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6716 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6717 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6718 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6719 * RTS threshold
6720 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6721 * if the selected rate supports it
6722 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6723 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6724 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6725 */
6726 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6727 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6728 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6729 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6730 struct sk_buff *skb;
6731 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6732 bool rts, short_preamble;
6733 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6734 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6735 bool bss;
6736 };
6737
6738 /**
6739 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6740 */
6741 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6742 /**
6743 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6744 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6745 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6746 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6747 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6748 */
6749 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6750 /**
6751 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6752 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6753 */
6754 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6755 };
6756
6757 struct rate_control_ops {
6758 unsigned long capa;
6759 const char *name;
6760 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6761 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6762 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6763 void (*free)(void *priv);
6764
6765 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6766 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6767 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6768 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6769 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6770 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6771 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6772 u32 changed);
6773 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6774 void *priv_sta);
6775
6776 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6777 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6778 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6779 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6780 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6781 struct sk_buff *skb);
6782 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6783 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6784
6785 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6786 struct dentry *dir);
6787
6788 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6789 };
6790
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)6791 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6792 enum nl80211_band band,
6793 int index)
6794 {
6795 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6796 }
6797
6798 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6799 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6800 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6801 {
6802 int i;
6803
6804 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6805 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6806 return i;
6807
6808 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6809 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6810
6811 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6812 return 0;
6813 }
6814
6815 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6816 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6817 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6818 {
6819 unsigned int i;
6820
6821 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6822 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6823 return true;
6824 return false;
6825 }
6826
6827 /**
6828 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6829 *
6830 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6831 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6832 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6833 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6834 *
6835 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6836 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6837 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6838 */
6839 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6840 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6841 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6842
6843 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6844 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6845
6846 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6847 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6848 {
6849 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6850 }
6851
6852 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6853 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6854 {
6855 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6856 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6857 }
6858
6859 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6860 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6861 {
6862 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6863 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6864 }
6865
6866 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6867 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6868 {
6869 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6870 }
6871
6872 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6873 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6874 {
6875 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6876 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6877 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6878 }
6879
6880 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6881 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6882 {
6883 if (p2p) {
6884 switch (type) {
6885 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6886 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6887 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6888 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6889 default:
6890 break;
6891 }
6892 }
6893 return type;
6894 }
6895
6896 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6897 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6898 {
6899 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6900 }
6901
6902 /**
6903 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6904 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6905 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6906 *
6907 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6908 */
6909 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6910 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6911 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6912 {
6913 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6914 }
6915
6916 /**
6917 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6918 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6919 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6920 *
6921 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6922 */
6923 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6924 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6925 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6926 {
6927 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6928 }
6929
6930 /**
6931 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6932 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6933 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6934 *
6935 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6936 */
6937 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6938 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6939 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6940 {
6941 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6942 }
6943
6944 /**
6945 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6946 *
6947 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6948 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6949 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6950 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6951 *
6952 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6953 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6954 * matching GroupId management frame.
6955 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6956 */
6957 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6958 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6959
6960 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6961 int rssi_min_thold,
6962 int rssi_max_thold);
6963
6964 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6965
6966 /**
6967 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6968 *
6969 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6970 *
6971 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6972 *
6973 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6974 * applicable.
6975 */
6976 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6977
6978 /**
6979 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6980 * @vif: virtual interface
6981 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6982 * @gfp: allocation flags
6983 *
6984 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6985 */
6986 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6987 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6988 gfp_t gfp);
6989
6990 /**
6991 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6992 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6993 * @vif: virtual interface
6994 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6995 * @band: the band to transmit on
6996 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6997 *
6998 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6999 */
7000 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7001 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7002 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7003
7004 /**
7005 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7006 * of injected frames.
7007 *
7008 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7009 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7010 * of the skb before calling this function.
7011 *
7012 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7013 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7014 */
7015 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7016 struct net_device *dev);
7017
7018 /**
7019 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7020 *
7021 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7022 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7023 *
7024 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7025 *
7026 * private:
7027 *
7028 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7029 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7030 */
7031 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7032 u32 next_tsf;
7033 bool has_next_tsf;
7034
7035 u8 absent;
7036
7037 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7038 struct {
7039 u32 start;
7040 u32 duration;
7041 u32 interval;
7042 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7043 };
7044
7045 /**
7046 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7047 *
7048 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7049 * @data: NoA tracking data
7050 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7051 *
7052 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7053 */
7054 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7055 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7056
7057 /**
7058 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7059 *
7060 * @data: NoA tracking data
7061 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7062 */
7063 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7064
7065 /**
7066 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7067 * @vif: virtual interface
7068 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7069 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7070 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7071 * @gfp: allocation flags
7072 *
7073 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7074 */
7075 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7076 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7077 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7078
7079 /**
7080 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7081 *
7082 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7083 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7084 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7085 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7086 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7087 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7088 *
7089 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7090 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7091 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7092 *
7093 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7094 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7095 *
7096 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7097 */
7098 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7099
7100 /**
7101 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7102 *
7103 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7104 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7105 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7106 *
7107 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7108 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7109 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7110 *
7111 * @sta: the station
7112 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7113 */
7114 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7115
7116 /**
7117 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7118 *
7119 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7120 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7121 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7122 *
7123 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7124 *
7125 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7126 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7127 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7128 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7129 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7130 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7131 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7132 *
7133 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7134 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7135 */
7136 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7137 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7138
7139 /**
7140 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7141 * (in process context)
7142 *
7143 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7144 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7145 *
7146 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7147 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7148 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7149 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7150 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7151 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7152 {
7153 struct sk_buff *skb;
7154
7155 local_bh_disable();
7156 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7157 local_bh_enable();
7158
7159 return skb;
7160 }
7161
7162 /**
7163 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7164 *
7165 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7166 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7167 *
7168 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7169 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7170 */
7171 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7172 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7173
7174 /**
7175 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7176 *
7177 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7178 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7179 *
7180 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7181 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7182 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7183 */
7184 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7185
7186 /**
7187 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7188 *
7189 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7190 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7191 *
7192 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7193 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7194 */
7195 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7196
7197 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7198 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7199 {
7200 }
7201
7202 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7203 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7204
7205 /**
7206 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7207 *
7208 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7209 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7210 *
7211 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7212 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7213 *
7214 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7215 * this TXQ internally.
7216 */
7217 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7218 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7219 {
7220 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7221 }
7222
7223 /**
7224 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7225 *
7226 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7227 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7228 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7229 *
7230 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7231 * internally.
7232 */
7233 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7234 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7235 bool force)
7236 {
7237 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7238 }
7239
7240 /**
7241 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7242 *
7243 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7244 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7245 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7246 * next_txq().
7247 *
7248 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7249 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7250 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7251 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7252 * again.
7253 *
7254 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7255 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7256 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7257 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7258 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7259 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7260 *
7261 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7262 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7263 */
7264 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7265 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7266
7267 /**
7268 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7269 *
7270 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7271 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7272 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7273 *
7274 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7275 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7276 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7277 */
7278 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7279 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7280 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7281
7282 /**
7283 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7284 *
7285 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7286 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7287 *
7288 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7289 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7290 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7291 * @gfp: allocation flags
7292 */
7293 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7294 u8 inst_id,
7295 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7296 gfp_t gfp);
7297
7298 /**
7299 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7300 *
7301 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7302 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7303 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7304 *
7305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7306 * @match: match event information
7307 * @gfp: allocation flags
7308 */
7309 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7310 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7311 gfp_t gfp);
7312
7313 /**
7314 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7315 *
7316 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7317 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7318 *
7319 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7320 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7321 * information.
7322 * @len: frame length in bytes
7323 */
7324 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7325 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7326 int len);
7327
7328 /**
7329 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7330 *
7331 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7332 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7333 *
7334 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7335 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7336 * @len: frame length in bytes
7337 */
7338 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7339 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7340 int len);
7341 /**
7342 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7343 *
7344 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7345 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7346 * hardware or firmware.
7347 *
7348 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7349 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7350 */
7351 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7352
7353 /**
7354 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7355 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7356 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7357 *
7358 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7359 *
7360 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7361 */
7362 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7363 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7364
7365 /**
7366 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7367 * probe response template.
7368 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7369 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7370 *
7371 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7372 *
7373 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7374 */
7375 struct sk_buff *
7376 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7377 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7378
7379 /**
7380 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7381 * collision.
7382 *
7383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7384 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7385 * aware of.
7386 * @gfp: allocation flags
7387 */
7388 void
7389 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7390 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7391
7392 /**
7393 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7394 *
7395 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7396 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7397 *
7398 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7399 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7400 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7401 {
7402 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7403 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7404
7405 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7406 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7407 }
7408
7409 /**
7410 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7411 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7412 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7413 *
7414 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7415 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7416 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7417 *
7418 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7419 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7420 * a sequence of calls like
7421 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7422 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7423 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7424 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7425 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7426 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7427 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7428 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7429 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7430 *
7431 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7432 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7433 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7434 */
7435 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7436
7437 /**
7438 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7439 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7440 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7441 *
7442 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7443 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7444 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7445 * completed after it returns.
7446 */
7447 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7448 u16 active_links);
7449
7450 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7451